blob: 587a76ed089515aafe348e8a3d6dfea4f8832adf [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000041
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc74073c2010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000100 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000101}
102
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000103/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000104/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000105/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
106///
107void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000109 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000110 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000111 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000112
113 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
114 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
116 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000117
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000118 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
119 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000120 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000121 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
122 int isMethod = 0;
123 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
124 // skip over named parameters.
125 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
126 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
127 if (nullPos)
128 --nullPos;
129 else
130 ++i;
131 }
132 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
133 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000134 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000135 // skip over named parameters.
136 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
137 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
138 if (nullPos)
139 --nullPos;
140 else
141 ++i;
142 }
143 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000144 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000145 // block or function pointer call.
146 QualType Ty = V->getType();
147 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000148 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000149 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
150 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000151 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
152 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
153 unsigned k;
154 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
155 if (nullPos)
156 --nullPos;
157 else
158 ++i;
159 }
160 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
161 }
162 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
163 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000164 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000165 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000166 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000167 return;
168
169 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000170 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000172 return;
173 }
174 int sentinel = i;
175 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
176 --sentinelPos;
177 ++i;
178 }
179 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
180 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000181 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000182 return;
183 }
184 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
185 ++i;
186 ++sentinel;
187 }
188 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000189 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
190 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
191 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000192 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
194 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
195 return;
196
197 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
198 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
199
200 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
201 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000202}
203
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000204SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
205 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
206 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
207}
208
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000209//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
210// Standard Promotions and Conversions
211//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
212
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
214void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
215 QualType Ty = E->getType();
216 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
217
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000218 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000219 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000220 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000221 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
222 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
223 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
224 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
225 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
226 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
227 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000228 //
229 // C++ 4.2p1:
230 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
231 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
232 //
233 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
234 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000235 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000236 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000237 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000238}
239
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000240void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
241 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000242
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000243 QualType Ty = E->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
245 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
246 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
247 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
248 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
249 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
250 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
251 // rvalue is T
252 //
253 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000254 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
255 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000256 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000257 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000258 }
259}
260
261
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000262/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000263/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000264/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
265/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
266/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
267Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
268 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
269 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000270
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000271 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
272 //
273 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
274 // unsigned int may be used:
275 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
276 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
277 // and unsigned int.
278 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
279 //
280 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
281 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
282 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
283 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000284 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
285 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000286 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000287 return Expr;
288 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000289 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000290 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000291 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000292 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000293 }
294
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000295 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000296 return Expr;
297}
298
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000299/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000300/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000301/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
302void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
303 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
304 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000305
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000306 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000307 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
308 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000309 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000310
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000311 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
312}
313
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
315/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
316/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
317/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000318bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
319 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000320 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000322 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
323 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
324 // etc.
325 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
326 return false;
327
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000328 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000329 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
330 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
331 << Expr->getType() << CT))
332 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000333
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000334 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000335 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000336 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
337 << Expr->getType() << CT))
338 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000339
340 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000341}
342
343
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000344/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
345/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000346/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000347/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
348/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
349/// GCC.
350QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
351 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000352 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000353 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000354
355 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000356
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000357 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000358 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000359 QualType lhs =
360 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000361 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000362 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363
364 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
365 if (lhs == rhs)
366 return lhs;
367
368 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
369 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
370 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
371 return lhs;
372
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000373 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000374 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000375 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
376 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000377 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000378 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
379 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
380
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000381 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000382 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000383 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
384 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000385 return destType;
386}
387
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000388//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
389// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
390//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
391
392
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000393/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000394/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
395/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
396/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
397/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000398///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000399ExprResult
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000400Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
402
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000403 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000404 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000405 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000406
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000407 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000408 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
409 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000410
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000411 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000412 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000413 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000414
415 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000416 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000417 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000418
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000419 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
420 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
421 // strings.
422 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000423 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000424 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000425
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000426 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000427 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
428 Literal.GetStringLength(),
429 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
430 &StringTokLocs[0],
431 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000432}
433
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000434/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
435/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
436/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
437/// for values inside the block or for globals).
438///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000439/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000440/// up-to-date.
441///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000443 ValueDecl *VD) {
444 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
445 // we wanted to.
446 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
447 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000448
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000449 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
450 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
451 return false;
452
453 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
454 // snapshot it.
455 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
456 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000457 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
458 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000460 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
461 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
462
463 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
464 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
465 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
466 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000467 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
468 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000469
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000470 if (!NextBlock)
471 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000472
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000473 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
474 // having a reference outside it.
475 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
476 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000477
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000478 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
479 // a snapshot as well.
480 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
481 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000482
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000483 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484}
485
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000486
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000487ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000488Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000489 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000490 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
491 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
492}
493
494/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000495ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000496Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
497 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
498 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000499 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000500 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000501 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000502 << D->getDeclName();
503 return ExprError();
504 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000505
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000506 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000507 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
508 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
509 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000510 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000511 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000512 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
513 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000514 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
515 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000516 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000517 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000518 << D->getIdentifier();
519 return ExprError();
520 }
521 }
522 }
523 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000524
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000525 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000526
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000527 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
528 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
529 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000530 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000531}
532
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
534/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
535/// actual member.
536///
537/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
538/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
539/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
540/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
541/// we found.
542///
543/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
544/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
545/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
546VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
547 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000548 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
549 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
550 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
551
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000552 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000553 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
554 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
555 do {
556 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000557 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000558 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000559 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000560 else {
561 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
562 break;
563 }
564 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000565 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000566 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000567
568 return BaseObject;
569}
570
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000571ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000572Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
573 FieldDecl *Field,
574 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
575 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
576 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000577 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000578 AnonFields);
579
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
581 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
582 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
583 // found via name lookup.
584 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000585 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000586 if (BaseObject) {
587 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
588 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000589 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000590 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patele25b5f82010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000591 Loc);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000592 BaseQuals
593 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000594 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
595 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
596 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
597 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
598 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000599 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000600 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
601 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
602 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000603 BaseQuals
604 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000605 } else {
606 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
607 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
608 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000609 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
610 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000611 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000612 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 = Context.getTagDeclType(
614 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
615 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000616 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000617 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
618 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
619 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000620 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000621 MD->getThisType(Context),
622 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000623 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
624 }
625 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000626 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
627 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000628 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000629 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000630 }
631
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000632 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000633 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
634 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 }
636
637 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
638 // anonymous struct/union.
639 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000640 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000641 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
642 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
643 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
644 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000645 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
646 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
647
648 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
649 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
650 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
651 ResultQuals.removeConst();
652
653 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
654 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
655
656 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
657 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
658
659 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
660 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
661 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
662
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000663 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000664 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000665 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000666 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
667 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000668 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000669 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000670 }
671
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000672 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000673}
674
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000675/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000676/// possibly a list of template arguments.
677///
678/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
679/// DecomposeTemplateName.
680///
681/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
682/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
683/// some way.
684static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
685 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
686 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000687 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000688 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
689 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
690 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
691 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
692
693 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
694 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
695 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
696 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
697 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
698
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000699 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000700 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
701 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000702 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
703 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000704 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000705 TemplateArgs = 0;
706 }
707}
708
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000709/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
710/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
711/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000712static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000713 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
714 return false;
715
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000716 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
717 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
718 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
719 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
720 if (!BaseRT) return false;
721
722 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000723 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000724 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
725 return false;
726 }
727
728 return true;
729}
730
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000731/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
732/// the prospective base classes.
733static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
734 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
735 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000736 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000737 return false;
738
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000739 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000740 if (!RD) return false;
741 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
742
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000743 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
744 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
745 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
746 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
747 if (!BaseRT) return false;
748
749 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000750 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
751 return false;
752 }
753
754 return true;
755}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000756
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000757enum IMAKind {
758 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
759 IMA_Static,
760
761 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
762 IMA_Mixed,
763
764 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
765 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
766 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
767
768 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
769 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
770 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
771
772 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
773 IMA_Instance,
774
775 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
776 IMA_Unresolved,
777
778 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
779 /// context is not an instance method.
780 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
781
782 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
783 /// non-class context.
784 IMA_AnonymousMember,
785
786 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
787 /// context is not an instance method.
788 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
789
790 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
791 /// class.
792 IMA_Error_Unrelated
793};
794
795/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
796/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
797/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
798/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
799/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
800/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
801static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
802 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000803 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000804
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000805 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000806 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000807 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
808 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000809
810 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
811 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
812
813 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
814 bool hasNonInstance = false;
815 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
816 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000817 NamedDecl *D = *I;
818 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000819 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
820
821 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
822 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
823 // that's a special case.
824 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
825 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
826 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
827 }
828 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
829 }
830 else
831 hasNonInstance = true;
832 }
833
834 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
835 // member reference.
836 if (Classes.empty())
837 return IMA_Static;
838
839 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
840 // an implicit member reference.
841 if (isStaticContext)
842 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
843
844 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
845 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
846 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
847 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000848 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000849 Classes))
850 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
851
852 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
853}
854
855/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
856static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
857 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
858 const LookupResult &R) {
859 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
860 SourceRange Range(Loc);
861 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
862
863 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
864 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
865 if (MD->isStatic()) {
866 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
867 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
868 << Range << R.getLookupName();
869 return;
870 }
871 }
872
873 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
874 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
875 return;
876 }
877
878 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000879}
880
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
882///
883/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000884bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
885 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000886 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
887
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000888 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000889 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000890 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
891 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000892 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000893 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000894 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
895 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000896
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000897 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
898 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
899 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
900 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000901 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000902 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000903 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
904 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
905
906 if (!R.empty()) {
907 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
908 R.suppressDiagnostics();
909
910 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
911 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
912 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
913 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
914
915 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
916 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
917 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000918 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000919 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
920 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000921 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000922 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000923 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000924 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
925 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
926 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
927 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
928 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
929 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
930 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
931 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
932 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
933 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
934 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
935 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
936 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
937 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000938 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000939 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
940 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
941 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000942 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000943 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000944 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000945 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000946
947 // Do we really want to note all of these?
948 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
949 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
950
951 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
952 return false;
953 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000954
955 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000956 }
957 }
958
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000959 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000960 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000961 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000962 if (!R.empty()) {
963 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
964 if (SS.isEmpty())
965 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
966 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
967 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
968 else
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
970 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
971 << SS.getRange()
972 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
973 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
974 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
975 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
976 << ND->getDeclName();
977
978 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
979 return false;
980 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000981
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000982 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
983 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
984 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
985 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
986 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
987 // to recover well anyway.
988 if (SS.isEmpty())
989 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
990 else
991 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
992 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
993 << SS.getRange();
994
995 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
996 return true;
997 }
998 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000999 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001000 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001001 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001002 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001003 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001004 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001005 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1006 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001007 return true;
1008 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001009 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001010 }
1011
1012 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1013 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1014 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1015 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1016 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1017 << SS.getRange();
1018 return true;
1019 }
1020
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001021 // Give up, we can't recover.
1022 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1023 return true;
1024}
1025
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001026static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001027 IdentifierInfo *II,
1028 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001029 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1030 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1031 if (!IDecl)
1032 return 0;
1033 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1034 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1035 return 0;
1036 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1037 if (!property)
1038 return 0;
1039 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1040 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1041 return 0;
1042 return property;
1043}
1044
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001045static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001046 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001047 IdentifierInfo *II,
1048 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1049 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001050 bool LookForIvars;
1051 if (Lookup.empty())
1052 LookForIvars = true;
1053 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1054 LookForIvars = false;
1055 else
1056 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1057 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1058 if (!LookForIvars)
1059 return 0;
1060
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001061 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1062 if (!IDecl)
1063 return 0;
1064 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001065 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1066 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001067 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1068 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1069 if (!property)
1070 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianbfcbc852010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001071 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001072 DynamicImplSeen =
1073 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanianbfcbc852010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001074 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1075 // one.
1076 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1077 return 0;
1078 }
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001079 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001080 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1081 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001082 NameLoc,
1083 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1084 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1085 (Expr *)0, true);
1086 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1087 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1088 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1089 return Ivar;
1090 }
1091 return 0;
1092}
1093
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001094ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001095 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1096 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1097 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1098 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001099 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1100 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1101
1102 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001103 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001104
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001105 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001106
1107 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001108 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001109 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001110 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001111
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001112 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001113 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001114 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001115
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001116 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1117 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001118 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1119 // (note: handled after lookup)
1120 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1121 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1122 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1124 // names a dependent type.
1125 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1126 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001127 bool DependentID = false;
1128 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1129 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1130 DependentID = true;
1131 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1132 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1133 if (DC) {
1134 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1135 return ExprError();
1136 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1137 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1138 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1139 } else {
1140 DependentID = true;
1141 }
1142 }
1143
1144 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001145 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001146 TemplateArgs);
1147 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001148 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001149 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001150 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001152 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1153 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1154 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1155 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1156 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001157 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1158 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1159 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001160 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001161 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001162 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001163
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001164 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1165 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001166 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001167 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 if (E.isInvalid())
1169 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001170
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001171 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1172 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001173 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1174 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001175 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001176 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1177 isAddressOfOperand);
1178 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001179 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1180 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001181 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001182 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001183
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001184 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1185 return ExprError();
1186
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001187 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1188 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001189 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001190
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001191 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001192 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001193 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1194 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1195 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1196 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1197 }
1198
1199 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1200 // call, diagnose the problem.
1201 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001202 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001203 return ExprError();
1204
1205 assert(!R.empty() &&
1206 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001207
1208 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1209 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001210 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001211 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1212 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001213 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001214 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1215 return move(E);
1216 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001217 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001218 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001219
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001220 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1221 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1222
1223 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001224 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001225 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1226 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001227 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1228 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1229 if (Property) {
1230 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1231 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001232 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001233 }
1234 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001235 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001236 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1237 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1238 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1239 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1240 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1241 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001242 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001243 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001244
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001245 QualType T = Func->getType();
1246 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001247 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001248 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1249 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001250 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001251 }
1252 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001253
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001254 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001255 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1256 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1257 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1258 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1259 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1260 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1261 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1262 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001263 //
1264 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1265 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1266 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1267 // non-static member function:
1268 //
1269 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1270 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1271 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1272 // member function call.
1273 //
1274 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1275 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1276 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1277 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001278 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001279 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1280 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1281 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1282 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1283 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1284 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1285 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001286 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1287 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001288 else
1289 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1290
1291 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001292 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001293 }
1294
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001295 if (TemplateArgs)
1296 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001297
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001298 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1299}
1300
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001301/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001302ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001303Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1304 LookupResult &R,
1305 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1306 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1307 case IMA_Instance:
1308 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1309
1310 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1311 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1312 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1313 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1314
1315 case IMA_Mixed:
1316 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1317 case IMA_Unresolved:
1318 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1319
1320 case IMA_Static:
1321 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1322 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1323 if (TemplateArgs)
1324 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1325 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1326
1327 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1328 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1329 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1330 return ExprError();
1331 }
1332
1333 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1334 return ExprError();
1335}
1336
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001337/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1338/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1339/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1340/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001341ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001342Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001343 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001344 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001345 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001346 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001347
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001348 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001349 return ExprError();
1350
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001351 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001352 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1353
1354 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1355 return ExprError();
1356
1357 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001358 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1359 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001360 return ExprError();
1361 }
1362
1363 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1364}
1365
1366/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1367/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1368/// additional lookup.
1369///
1370/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1371/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1372///
1373/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001374ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001375Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001376 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001377 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001378 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001379
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001380 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1381 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1382 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1383 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1384 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1385
1386 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1387 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1388 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001389 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001390
1391 bool LookForIvars;
1392 if (Lookup.empty())
1393 LookForIvars = true;
1394 else if (IsClassMethod)
1395 LookForIvars = false;
1396 else
1397 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1398 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001399 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001400 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001401 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001402 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1403 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1404 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1405 if (IsClassMethod)
1406 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1407 << IV->getDeclName());
1408
1409 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1410 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1411 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1412 return ExprError();
1413
1414 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1415 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1416 return ExprError();
1417
1418 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1419 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1420 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1421 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1422
1423 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1424 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1425 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1426 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001427 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001428 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001429 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregora1ed39b2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001430 SelfName, false, false);
1431 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1432 return ExprError();
1433
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001434 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1435 return Owned(new (Context)
1436 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1437 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1438 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001439 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001440 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001441 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001442 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1443 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1444 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1445 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1446 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1447 }
1448 }
1449
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001450 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1451 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1452 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1453 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1454 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1455 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1456 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1457 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1458 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1459 }
1460 }
1461 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001462 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1463 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001464}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001465
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001466/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1467///
1468/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1469///
1470/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1471/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1472/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1473/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1474///
1475/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1476/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1477/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1478/// the class declaring the member.
1479///
1480/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1481/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1482/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001483bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001484Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1485 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001486 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001487 NamedDecl *Member) {
1488 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1489 if (!RD)
1490 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001491
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 QualType DestRecordType;
1493 QualType DestType;
1494 QualType FromRecordType;
1495 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1496 bool PointerConversions = false;
1497 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1498 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001499
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001500 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1501 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1502 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1503 PointerConversions = true;
1504 } else {
1505 DestType = DestRecordType;
1506 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001507 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001508 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1509 if (Method->isStatic())
1510 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001511
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001512 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1513 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001514
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001515 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1516 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1517 PointerConversions = true;
1518 } else {
1519 FromRecordType = FromType;
1520 DestType = DestRecordType;
1521 }
1522 } else {
1523 // No conversion necessary.
1524 return false;
1525 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001526
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001527 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1528 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001529
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001530 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1531 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1532 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001533
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001534 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1535 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1536
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001537 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001538
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001539 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001540 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001541 // class name.
1542 //
1543 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1544 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1545 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1546 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1547 //
1548 // class Base { public: int x; };
1549 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1550 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1551 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1552 //
1553 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1554 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1555 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1556 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001557 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001558 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1559 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1560 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1561
1562 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1563
1564 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1565 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1566 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1567 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001568 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001569 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001570 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001571 return true;
1572
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001573 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001574 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001575 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1576 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001577
1578 FromType = QType;
1579 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1580
1581 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1582 // we're done.
1583 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1584 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001585 }
1586 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001587
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001588 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001589
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001590 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1591 // down to the using declaration's type.
1592 //
1593 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1594 // class ever has member declarations.
1595 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1596 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1597 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1598 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1599
1600 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1601 // conversion is non-trivial.
1602 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1603 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001604 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001605 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001606 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001607 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001608
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001609 QualType UType = URecordType;
1610 if (PointerConversions)
1611 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001612 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001613 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001614 FromType = UType;
1615 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1616 }
1617
1618 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1619 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1620 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001621 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001622
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001623 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001624 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1625 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001626 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001627 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001628
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001629 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001630 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001631 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001632}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001633
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001634/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001635static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001636 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001637 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001638 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1639 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001640 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1641 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1642 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001643 if (SS.isSet()) {
1644 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1645 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001646 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001647
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001648 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001649 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1650 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001651}
1652
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001653/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1654/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1655/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1656/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001657ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001658Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1659 LookupResult &R,
1660 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1661 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001662 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1663
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001664 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001665
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001666 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1667 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001668 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001669 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001670 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001671 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001672 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001673
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001674 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1675 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001676 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1677 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001678 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1679 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001680 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1681 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1682 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1683 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001684 }
1685
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001686 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001687 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1688 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001689 SS,
1690 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1691 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001692}
1693
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001694bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001695 const LookupResult &R,
1696 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001697 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1698 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1699 return false;
1700
1701 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001702 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001703 return false;
1704
1705 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001706 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001707 return false;
1708
1709 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1710 // normal lookup:
1711 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1712 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1713
1714 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1715 // -- a declaration of a class member
1716 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1717 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001718 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001719 return false;
1720
1721 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1722 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1723 // using-declaration
1724 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1725 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1726 // turn off ADL anyway).
1727 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1728 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1729 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1730 return false;
1731
1732 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1733 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1734 // template
1735 // And also for builtin functions.
1736 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1737 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1738
1739 // But also builtin functions.
1740 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1741 return false;
1742 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1743 return false;
1744 }
1745
1746 return true;
1747}
1748
1749
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001750/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1751/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1752/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1753/// will in fact be used.
1754static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1755 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1756 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1757 return true;
1758 }
1759
1760 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1761 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1762 return true;
1763 }
1764
1765 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1766 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1767 return true;
1768 }
1769
1770 return false;
1771}
1772
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001773ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001774Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001775 LookupResult &R,
1776 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001777 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1778 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001779 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001780 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1781 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001782
1783 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1784 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1785 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001786 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1787 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001788 return ExprError();
1789
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001790 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1791 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1792 // we've picked a target.
1793 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1794
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001795 bool Dependent
1796 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001797 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001798 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001799 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001800 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001801 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1802 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001803
1804 return Owned(ULE);
1805}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001806
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001807
1808/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001809ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001810Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001811 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1812 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001813 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001814 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1815 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001816
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001817 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001818 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1819 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001820
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001821 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1822 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1823 // a template argument list.
1824 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1825 << Template << SS.getRange();
1826 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1827 return ExprError();
1828 }
1829
1830 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1831 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1832 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001833 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001834 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001835 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001836 return ExprError();
1837 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001838
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001839 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1840 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1841 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1842 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001843 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001844 return ExprError();
1845
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001846 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1847 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001848 return ExprError();
1849
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001850 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1851 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1852 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1853 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001854 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001855 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1856 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1857 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001858 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001859 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001860 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1861 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1862 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1863 return ExprError();
1864 }
1865
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001866 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001867 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1868 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1869 return ExprError();
1870 }
1871
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001872 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001873 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001874 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001875 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001876 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001877 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1878 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001879 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001880
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001881 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001882 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001883 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1884 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001885 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001886 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1887 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1888 Expr *E = new (Context)
1889 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1890 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001891
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001892 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001893 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001894 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001895 SourceLocation(),
1896 Owned(E));
1897 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001898 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001899 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1900 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1901 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001902 }
1903 }
1904 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001905 }
1906 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1907 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001908
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001909 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1910 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001911}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001912
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001913ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001914 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001915 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001917 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001918 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001919 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1920 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1921 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001922 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001923
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001924 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1925 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001926
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001927 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001928 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1929 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001930 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001931 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001932 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001933 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001934
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001935 QualType ResTy;
1936 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1937 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1938 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001939 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001940
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001941 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001942 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001943 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1944 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001945 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001946}
1947
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001948ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001949 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001950 bool Invalid = false;
1951 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1952 if (Invalid)
1953 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001954
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001955 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1956 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001957 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001958 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001959
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001960 QualType Ty;
1961 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1962 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1963 else if (Literal.isWide())
1964 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001965 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1966 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001967 else
1968 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001969
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001970 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1971 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001972 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001973}
1974
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001975ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001977 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1978 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001979 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001980 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001981 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001982 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001983 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001984
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001985 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001986 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1987 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001988 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001989
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001990 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001991 bool Invalid = false;
1992 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1993 if (Invalid)
1994 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001995
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001996 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001997 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001998 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001999 return ExprError();
2000
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002001 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002002
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002003 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002004 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002005 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002006 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002007 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002008 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002009 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002010 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002011
2012 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2013
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002014 using llvm::APFloat;
2015 APFloat Val(Format);
2016
2017 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002018
2019 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2020 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2021 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2022 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002023 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002024 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002025 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002026 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002027 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2028 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002029 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002030 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2031 }
2032
2033 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2034 << Ty
2035 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2036 }
2037
2038 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002039 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002040
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002041 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002042 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002043 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002044 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002045
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002046 // long long is a C99 feature.
2047 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002048 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002049 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2050
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002051 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002052 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002053
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002054 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2055 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2056 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002057 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2058 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002059 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002060 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002061 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2062 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002063
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002064 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2065 // be an unsigned int.
2066 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2067
2068 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002069 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002070 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2071 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002072 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002073
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002074 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2075 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2076 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2077 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002078 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002079 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002080 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002081 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002082 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002083 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002084
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002085 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002086 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002087 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002088
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002089 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2090 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2091 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2092 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002093 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002094 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002095 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002096 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002097 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002098 }
2099
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002100 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002101 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002102 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002103
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002104 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2105 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2106 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2107 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002108 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002109 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002110 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002111 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002112 }
2113 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002114
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002115 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2116 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002117 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002118 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002119 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002120 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002121 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002122
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002123 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2124 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002125 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002126 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002127 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002128
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002129 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2130 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002131 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002132 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002133
2134 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002135}
2136
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002137ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002138 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002139 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002140 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002141}
2142
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002143/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002144/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002145bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002146 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002147 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002148 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002149 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2150 return false;
2151
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002152 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2153 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2154 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2155 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2156 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2157 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2158
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002159 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002160 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002161 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002162 if (isSizeof)
2163 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2164 return false;
2165 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002166
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002167 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002168 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002169 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2170 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002171 return false;
2172 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002173
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002174 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002175 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2176 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002177 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002178
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002179 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002180 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002181 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002182 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2183 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002184 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002185
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002186 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002187}
2188
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002189static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2190 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002191 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002192
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002193 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002194 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2195 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002196
2197 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2198 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2199 return false;
2200
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002201 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002202 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002203 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002204 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002205
2206 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2207 // bit-field.
2208 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002209 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002210 return false;
2211
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002212 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002213}
2214
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002215/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002216ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002217Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002218 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002219 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002220 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002221 return ExprError();
2222
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002223 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002224
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002225 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2226 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2227 return ExprError();
2228
2229 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002230 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002231 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2232 R.getEnd()));
2233}
2234
2235/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2236/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002237ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002238Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002239 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2240 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2241 bool isInvalid = false;
2242 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2243 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2244 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002245 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002246 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002247 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2248 isInvalid = true;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002249 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2250 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2251 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2252 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002253 } else {
2254 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2255 }
2256
2257 if (isInvalid)
2258 return ExprError();
2259
2260 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2261 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2262 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2263 R.getEnd()));
2264}
2265
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002266/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2267/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2268/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002269ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002270Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2271 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002272 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002273 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002274
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002275 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002276 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002277 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002278 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002279 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002280
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002281 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002282 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002283 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2284
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002285 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002286}
2287
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002288QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002289 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2290 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002291
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002292 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002293 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002294 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002295
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002296 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2297 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2298 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002299
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002300 // Test for placeholders.
2301 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2302 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2303 if (PR.take() != V) {
2304 V = PR.take();
2305 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2306 }
2307
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002308 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002309 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2310 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002311 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002312}
2313
2314
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002315
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002316ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002317Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002318 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002319 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002320 switch (Kind) {
2321 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002322 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2323 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002324 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002325
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002326 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002327}
2328
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002329ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002330Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2331 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002332 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002333 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002334 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2335 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002336
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002337 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002338
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002339 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002340 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002341 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2342 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2343 }
2344
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002345 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002346 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002347 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2348 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2349 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002350 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002351 }
2352
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002353 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002354}
2355
2356
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002357ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002358Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2359 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2360 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2361 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002362
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002363 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002364 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2365 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2366 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002367
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002368 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002369
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002370 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002371 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002372 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002373 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002374 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2375 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002376 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2377 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2378 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2379 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002380 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002381 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2382 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002383 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002384 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002385 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002386 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2387 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002388 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002389 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002390 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002391 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2392 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2393 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002394 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002395 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002396 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2397 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2398 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2399 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002400 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002401 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002402 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002403
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002404 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2405 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002406 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2407 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002408 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002409 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2410 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2411 // force the promotion here.
2412 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2413 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002414 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002415 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002416 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2417
2418 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2419 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002420 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002421 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2422 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2423 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2424 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002425 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002426 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002427 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2428
2429 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2430 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002431 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002432 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002433 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2434 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002435 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002436 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002437 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002438 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2439 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002440
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002441 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002442 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2443 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002444 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2445
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002446 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002447 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2448 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002449 // incomplete types are not object types.
2450 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2451 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2452 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2453 return ExprError();
2454 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002455
Abramo Bagnara3aabb4b2010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002456 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2457 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2458 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2459 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2460 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002461 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002462 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2463 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002464 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002465
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002466 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002467 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002468 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2469 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2470 return ExprError();
2471 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002472
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002473 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002474 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002475}
2476
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002477QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002478CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002479 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002480 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002481 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2482 // see FIXME there.
2483 //
2484 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2485 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002486 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002487
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002488 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002489 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002490
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002491 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002492 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2493 // to be selected.
2494 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002495
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002496 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2497 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002498 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002499
2500 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2501 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002502 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002503 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2504 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002505 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002506 do
2507 compStr++;
2508 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002509 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002510 do
2511 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002512 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002513 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002514
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002515 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002516 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2517 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002518 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002519 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002520 return QualType();
2521 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002522
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002523 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2524 // operates on.
2525 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002526 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002527
2528 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002529 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002530
2531 while (*compStr) {
2532 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2533 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2534 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2535 return QualType();
2536 }
2537 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002538 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002539
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002540 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002541 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002542 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002543 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002544 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002545 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002546 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002547 if (HexSwizzle)
2548 CompSize--;
2549
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002550 if (CompSize == 1)
2551 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002552
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002553 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002554 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002555 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2556 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2557 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2558 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002559 }
2560 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002561}
2562
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002563static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002564 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002565 const Selector &Sel,
2566 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002567 if (Member)
2568 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2569 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002570 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002571 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002572
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002573 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2574 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002575 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2576 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002577 return D;
2578 }
2579 return 0;
2580}
2581
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002582static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2583 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2584 const Selector &Sel,
2585 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002586 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2587 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002588 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002589 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002590 if (Member)
2591 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2592 GDecl = PD;
2593 break;
2594 }
2595 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002596 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002597 GDecl = OMD;
2598 break;
2599 }
2600 }
2601 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002602 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002603 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2604 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002605 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2606 Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002607 if (GDecl)
2608 return GDecl;
2609 }
2610 }
2611 return GDecl;
2612}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002613
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002614ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002615Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002616 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002617 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2618 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002619 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002620 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002621 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2622 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2623 //
2624 // T* t;
2625 // t.f;
2626 //
2627 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2628 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2629 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2630 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002631 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002632 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2633 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002634 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002635 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002636 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002637 return ExprError();
2638 }
2639 }
2640
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002641 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2642 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002643 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002644
2645 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2646 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002647 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002648 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002649 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002650 SS.getRange(),
2651 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002652 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002653}
2654
2655/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2656/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2657/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2658static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2659 Expr *BaseExpr,
2660 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002661 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002662 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002663 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2664 // diagnostics.
2665 if (!BaseExpr)
2666 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002667
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002668 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2669 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002670}
2671
2672// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2673// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2674// type. The restriction here is:
2675//
2676// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2677// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2678// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2679//
2680// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2681// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2682// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2683// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2684bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2685 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002686 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002687 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2689 if (!BaseRT) {
2690 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2691 // dependent.
2692 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2693 return false;
2694 }
2695 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002696
2697 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002698 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2699 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002700 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002701 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002702
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002703 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002704 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2705 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2706 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002707
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002708 if (!DC->isRecord())
2709 continue;
2710
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002711 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002712 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002713
2714 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2715 return false;
2716 }
2717
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002718 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002719 return true;
2720}
2721
2722static bool
2723LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2724 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002725 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2726 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002727 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2728 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002729 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002730 << BaseRange))
2731 return true;
2732
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002733 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2734 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2735 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2736
2737 bool MOUS;
2738 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2739 return false;
2740 }
2741
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002742 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2743 if (SS.isSet()) {
2744 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2745 // nested-name-specifier.
2746 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2747
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002748 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002749 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2750 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2751 return true;
2752 }
2753
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002754 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002755
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002756 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2757 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2758 << DC << SS.getRange();
2759 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002760 }
2761 }
2762
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002763 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2764 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002766 if (!R.empty())
2767 return false;
2768
2769 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2770 // for typos.
2771 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002772 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002773 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002774 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2775 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2776 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002777 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2778 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002779 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2780 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2781 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002782 return false;
2783 } else {
2784 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002785 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002786 }
2787
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002788 return false;
2789}
2790
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002791ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002792Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002793 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002794 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002795 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002796 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002797 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002798 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2799 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002800 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002801 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2802 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002803 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002804
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002805 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002806
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002807 // Implicit member accesses.
2808 if (!Base) {
2809 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2810 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2811 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2812 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002813 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002814 return ExprError();
2815
2816 // Explicit member accesses.
2817 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002818 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002819 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002820 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002821
2822 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2823 Owned(Base);
2824 return ExprError();
2825 }
2826
2827 if (Result.get())
2828 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002829
2830 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2831 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002832 }
2833
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002834 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002835 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2836 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002837}
2838
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002839ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002840Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002841 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2842 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002843 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002844 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002845 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2846 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002847 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002848 if (IsArrow) {
2849 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2850 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2851 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002852 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002853
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002854 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002855 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2856 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2857 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002858
2859 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002860 return ExprError();
2861
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002862 if (R.empty()) {
2863 // Rederive where we looked up.
2864 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2865 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2866 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002867
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002868 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002869 << MemberName << DC
2870 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002871 return ExprError();
2872 }
2873
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002874 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2875 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2876 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2877 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2878 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2879 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2880 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2881 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2882 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2883 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002884 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002885 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002886 return ExprError();
2887
2888 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2889 // result.
2890 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002891 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002892 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002893 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002894 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002895
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002896 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2897 // pick a member.
2898 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2899
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002900 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2901 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2902 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002903 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2904 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002905 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002906 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002907 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002908
2909 return Owned(MemExpr);
2910 }
2911
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002912 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002913 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002914 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2915
2916 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2917
2918 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2919 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2920 // error cases.
2921 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2922 return ExprError();
2923
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002924 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2925 if (!BaseExpr) {
2926 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002927 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002928 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002929
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002930 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2931 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2932 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2933 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002934 }
2935
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002936 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2937 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2938 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2939 // explicitly qualified.
2940 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2941 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2942 }
2943
2944 // Check the use of this member.
2945 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2946 Owned(BaseExpr);
2947 return ExprError();
2948 }
2949
2950 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2951 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2952 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002953 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2954 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002955 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2956 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2957
2958 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2959 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2960 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2961 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2962 else {
2963 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2964 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2965 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2966
2967 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2968 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2969
2970 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2971 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2972 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2973 }
2974
2975 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002976 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002977 return ExprError();
2978 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002979 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2980 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981 }
2982
2983 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2984 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2985 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002986 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002987 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2988 }
2989
2990 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2991 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2992 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002993 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002994 MemberFn->getType()));
2995 }
2996
2997 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2998 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2999 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003000 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3001 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003002 }
3003
3004 Owned(BaseExpr);
3005
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003006 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003007 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003008 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003009 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3010 else
3011 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3012 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003013
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003014 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3015 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003016 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003017 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003018}
3019
3020/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3021/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3022/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3023/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3024/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3025/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3026/// an ordinary member expression.
3027///
3028/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3029/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003030ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003031Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003032 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003033 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003034 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003035 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003036
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003037 // Perform default conversions.
3038 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003039
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003040 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003041 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3042
3043 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3044 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003045
3046 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003047 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003048 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3049 // call, and continue on.
3050 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3051 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3052 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3053 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3054 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003055 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3056 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003057 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3058 ->isRecordType()))) {
3059 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewyckyc60d6e72010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003060 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003061 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003062 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003063
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003064 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003065 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003066 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003067 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003068 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003069
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003070 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3071 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3072 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3073 }
3074 }
3075 }
3076
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003077 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3078 // use that.
3079 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003080 if (IsArrow) {
3081 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3082 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3083 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003084 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003085 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003086 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3087 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003088 }
3089 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003090 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3091 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3092 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3093 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003094 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003095 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003096 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003097
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003098 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3099 // use that.
3100 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3101 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3102 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3103 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3104 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003105 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003106 }
3107 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003108
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003109 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003110
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003111 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003112 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003113 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3114 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3115 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3116 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3117 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3118 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3119 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3120 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3121 // Check the use of this method.
3122 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3123 return ExprError();
3124 }
3125 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3126 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3127 Selector SetterSel =
3128 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3129 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3130 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3131 if (!Setter) {
3132 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3133 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003134 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003135 }
3136 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3137 if (!Setter)
3138 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003139
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003140 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3141 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003142
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003143 if (Getter || Setter) {
3144 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003145
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003146 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003147 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003148 else
3149 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3150 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3151 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003152 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003153 PType,
3154 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3155 }
3156 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3157 << MemberName << BaseType);
3158 }
3159 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003160
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003161 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3162 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3163 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003164 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003165 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003166
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003167 if (IsArrow) {
3168 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003169 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003170 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3171 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003172 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3173 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3174 // struct MyRecord foo;
3175 // foo->bar
3176 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3177 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3178 // by now.
3179 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3180 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003181 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003182 IsArrow = false;
3183 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003184 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3185 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3186 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003187 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003188 } else {
3189 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3190 // type *foo;
3191 // foo.bar
3192 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3193 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3194 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3195 // the appropriate pointer type
3196 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3197 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3198 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3199 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3200 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003201 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003202 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3203 IsArrow = true;
3204 }
3205 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003206 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003207
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003208 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003209 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003210 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003211 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003212 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003213 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003214 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003215
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003216 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3217 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003218 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003219 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003220 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003221 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3222 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3223 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3224 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003225 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3226
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003227 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003228 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003229
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003230 if (!IV) {
3231 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3232 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3233 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregord507d772010-10-20 03:06:34 +00003234 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3235 IsArrow? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3236 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003237 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003238 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003239 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3240 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003241 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3242 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003243 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003244 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003245 } else {
3246 Res.clear();
3247 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003248 }
3249 }
3250
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003251 if (IV) {
3252 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3253 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3254 // error cases.
3255 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3256 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003257
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003258 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3259 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3260 return ExprError();
3261 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3262 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3263 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3264 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3265 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3266 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3267 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3268 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3269 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3270 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3271 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3272 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003273 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003274 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003275 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3276 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003277 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003278 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3279 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003280
3281 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3282 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003283 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003284 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003285 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003286 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3287 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003288 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003289 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003290 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003291
3292 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3293 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003294 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003295 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003296 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003297 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003298 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003299 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003300 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003301 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003302 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3303 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003304 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003305 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003306
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003307 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003308 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003309 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3310 Context)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003311 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3312 // Check the use of this declaration
3313 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3314 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003315
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003316 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003317 MemberLoc,
3318 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003319 }
3320 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3321 // Check the use of this method.
3322 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3323 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003324 Selector SetterSel =
3325 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3326 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3327 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3328 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3329 SetterSel, Context))
3330 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3331 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3332 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3333 SMD,
3334 MemberLoc,
3335 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003336 }
3337 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003338
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003339 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003340 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003341 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003342
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003343 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3344 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003345 if (!IsArrow)
3346 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3347 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003348 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3349 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003350
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003351 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003352 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003353 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3354 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003355 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003356 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003357 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003358
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003359 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003360 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003361 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003362 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3363 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003364 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003365 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003366 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003367 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003368
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003369 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3370 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3371
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003372 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003373}
3374
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003375/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3376/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3377/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3378/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3379/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3380///
3381/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3382/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3383/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3384/// only be called
3385/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3386/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3387/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003388ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003389 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3390 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003391 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003392 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003393 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003394 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3395 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3396 return ExprError();
3397
3398 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3399
3400 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003401 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003402 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3403 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003404 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003405
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003406 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003407 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3408
3409 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3410 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3411 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3412
3413 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003414 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003415 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3416 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003417
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003418 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3419 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003420 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003421 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3422 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003423 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003424 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003425 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003426 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3427 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003428
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003429 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3430 Owned(Base);
3431 return ExprError();
3432 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003433
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003434 if (Result.get()) {
3435 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3436 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3437 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3438 // call now.
3439 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3440 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003441 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003442
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003443 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003444 }
3445
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003446 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003447 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3448 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003449 }
3450
3451 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003452}
3453
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003454ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003455 FunctionDecl *FD,
3456 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3457 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003458 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003459 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3460 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003461 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003462 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003463 return ExprError();
3464 }
3465
3466 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3467 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003468
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003469 // Instantiate the expression.
3470 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3471 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003472
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003473 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3474 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3475 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3476 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003477
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003478 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3479 if (Result.isInvalid())
3480 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003481
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003482 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3483 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003484 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003485 InitializationKind Kind
3486 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3487 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3488 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003489
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003490 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3491 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3492 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3493 if (Result.isInvalid())
3494 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003495
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003496 // Build the default argument expression.
3497 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3498 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003499 }
3500
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003501 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3502 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3503 // be properly destroyed.
3504 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3505 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003506 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3507 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3508 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3509 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3510 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3511 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003512
3513 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003514 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3515 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003516 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003517 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003518}
3519
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003520/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3521/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3522/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3523/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3524/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3525/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003526bool
3527Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003528 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003529 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003530 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3531 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003532 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003533 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3534 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003535 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003536
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003537 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3538 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3539 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3540 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3541 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003542 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003543 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003544 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003545 }
3546
3547 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3548 // them.
3549 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3550 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3551 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3552 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003553 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003554 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003555 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3556 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3557 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003558 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003559 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003560 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003561 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003562 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003563 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003564 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3565 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3566 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3567 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3568 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003569 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003570 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003571 if (Invalid)
3572 return true;
3573 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3574 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3575 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003576
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003577 return false;
3578}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003579
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003580bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3581 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3582 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3583 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3584 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3585 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003586 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003587 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3588 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3589 bool Invalid = false;
3590 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3591 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3592 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3593 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003594 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003595 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003596 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003597
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003598 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003599 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3600 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003601
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003602 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3603 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003604 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003605 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003606 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003607
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003608 // Pass the argument
3609 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3610 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3611 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003612
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003613 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003614 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3615 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003616 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003617 SourceLocation(),
3618 Owned(Arg));
3619 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3620 return true;
3621
3622 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003623 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003624 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003625
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003626 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003627 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003628 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3629 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003630
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003631 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003632 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003633 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003634 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003635
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003636 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003637 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003638 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003639 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003640 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003641 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003642 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003643 }
3644 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003645 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003646}
3647
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003648/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003649/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3650/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003651ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003652Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003653 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003654 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003655
3656 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003657 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003658 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3659 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003660
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003661 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003662
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003663 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003664 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3665 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3666 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3667 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3668 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003669 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003670 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3671 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003672
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003673 NumArgs = 0;
3674 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003675
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003676 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3677 RParenLoc));
3678 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003679
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003680 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003681 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003682 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3683 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003684 bool Dependent = false;
3685 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3686 Dependent = true;
3687 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3688 Dependent = true;
3689
3690 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003691 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003692 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3693
3694 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3695 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3696 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003697 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003698
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003699 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3700
3701 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3702 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3703 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3704 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3705 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3706 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3707 // method template.
3708 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003709 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3710 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003711 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003712
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003713 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003714 RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003715 }
3716
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003717 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003718 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003719 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003720 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003721 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003722 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003723 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003724
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003725 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003726 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003727 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3728 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003729 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3730 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003731 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003732
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003733 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3734 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3735 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3736 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003737
3738 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3739 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003740 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003741 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003742
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003743 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003744 RParenLoc))
3745 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003746
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003747 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003748 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003749 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003750 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3751 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003752 }
3753 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003754 }
3755
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003756 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003757 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003758 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003759
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003760 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003761 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3762 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003763 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003764 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003765 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003766
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003767 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3768 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3769 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3770
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003771 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3772}
3773
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003774/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3775/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003776/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3777/// block-pointer type.
3778///
3779/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003780ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003781Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3782 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3783 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3784 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3785 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3786
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003787 // Promote the function operand.
3788 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3789
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003790 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3791 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003792 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3793 Args, NumArgs,
3794 Context.BoolTy,
3795 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003796
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003797 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3798 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3799 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3800 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003801 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003802 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003803 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3804 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003805 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003806 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003807 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003808 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003809 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003810 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003811 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3812 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3813
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003814 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003815 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003816 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003817 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003818 return ExprError();
3819
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003820 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003821 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003822
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003823 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003824 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003825 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003826 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003827 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003828 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003829
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003830 if (FDecl) {
3831 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3832 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3833 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003834 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003835 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003836 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003837 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3838 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3839 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3840 }
3841 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003842 }
3843
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003844 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003845 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3846 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3847 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003848 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3849 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003850 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3851 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003852 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003853 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003854 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003855 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003856
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003857 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3858 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003859 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3860 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003861
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003862 // Check for sentinels
3863 if (NDecl)
3864 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003865
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003866 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003867 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003868 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003869 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003870
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003871 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003872 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003873 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003874 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003875 return ExprError();
3876 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003877
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003878 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003879}
3880
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003881ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003882Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003883 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003884 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003885 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003886 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003887
3888 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3889 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3890 if (!TInfo)
3891 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3892
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003893 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003894}
3895
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003896ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003897Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003898 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003899 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003900
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003901 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003902 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003903 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3904 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003905 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3906 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003907 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003908 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003909 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003910 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003911
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003912 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003913 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003914 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003915 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003916 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003917 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003918 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003919 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003920 &literalType);
3921 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003922 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003923 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003924
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003925 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003926 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003927 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003928 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003929 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003930
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003931 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003932 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003933}
3934
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003935ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003936Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003937 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3938 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003939 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003940
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003941 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003942 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003943
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003944 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3945 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003946 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003947 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003948}
3949
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003950static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003951 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003952 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003953 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003954
3955 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3956 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003957 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003958 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3959 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003960 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003961 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003962 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003963
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003964 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3965 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003966 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003967 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003968 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003969 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003970 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003971 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003972
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003973 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3974 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003975 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003976 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003977 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003978 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003979
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003980 // FIXME: Assert here.
3981 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003982 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003983}
3984
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003985/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003986bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003987 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003988 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003989 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003990 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003991 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3992 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003993
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003994 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003995
3996 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3997 // type needs to be scalar.
3998 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3999 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004000 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004001 return false;
4002 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004003
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004004 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4005 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4006 return true;
4007
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004008 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004009 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004010 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4011 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004012 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004013 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4014 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004015 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004016 return false;
4017 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004018
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004019 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004020 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004021 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004022 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004023 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004024 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004025 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara5d3e7242010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004026 castExpr->getType()) &&
4027 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004028 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4029 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4030 break;
4031 }
4032 }
4033 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4034 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4035 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004036 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004037 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004038 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004039
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004040 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4041 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4042 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4043 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004044
4045 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004046 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004047 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4048 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004049 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004050 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004051
4052 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004053 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004054
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004055 if (castType->isVectorType())
4056 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4057 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4058 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4059
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004060 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4061 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004062
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004063 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004064 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004065 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004066 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004067 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4068 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4069 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4070 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004071 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004072 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4073 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4074 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004075 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004076
4077 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004078
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004079 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004080 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4081
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004082 return false;
4083}
4084
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004085bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004086 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004087 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004088
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004089 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004090 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004091 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004092 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004093 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004094 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004095 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004096 } else
4097 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004098 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004099 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004100
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004101 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004102 return false;
4103}
4104
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004105bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004106 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004107 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004108
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004109 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004110
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004111 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4112 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004113 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4114 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4115 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4116 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004117 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004118 return false;
4119 }
4120
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004121 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004122 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4123 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004124 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4125 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4126 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4127 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004128
4129 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4130 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4131 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004132
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004133 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004134 return false;
4135}
4136
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004137ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004138Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004139 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4140 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004141 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004142
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004143 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4144 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4145 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004146 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004147
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004148 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4149 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004150 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004151 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004152
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004153 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004154}
4155
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004156ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004157Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004158 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004159 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004160 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004161 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004162 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004163 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004164
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004165 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004166 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004167 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4168 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004169}
4170
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004171/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4172/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004173ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004174Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004175 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4176 if (!E)
4177 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004178
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004179 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004180
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004181 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004182 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4183 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004184
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004185 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4186
4187 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004188}
4189
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004190ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004191Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004192 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004193 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004194 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004195 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004196 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004197
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004198 // Check for an altivec literal,
4199 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004200 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4201 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4202 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4203 return ExprError();
4204 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004205 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4206 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4207 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4208 }
4209 else
4210 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4211 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004212
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004213 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4214 // then handle it as such.
4215 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004216 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4217 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4218 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4219
4220 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4221 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004222 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4223 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004224 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4225 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004226 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004227 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004228 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004229 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004230 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004231 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4232 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004233 }
4234}
4235
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004236ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004237 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004238 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004239 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004240 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4241 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004242 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4243 Expr *expr;
4244 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4245 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4246 else
4247 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004248 return Owned(expr);
4249}
4250
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004251/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4252/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004253/// C99 6.5.15
4254QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004255 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004256 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004257 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4258 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004259 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004260
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004261 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004262 if (SAVE) {
4263 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4264 }
4265 else
4266 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004267 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4268 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4269 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4270 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004271
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004272 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004273 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004274 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4275 // Throw an error if its not either.
4276 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4277 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4278 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4279 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4280 << CondTy;
4281 return QualType();
4282 }
4283 }
4284 else {
4285 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4286 << CondTy;
4287 return QualType();
4288 }
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004289 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004290
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004291 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004292 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4293 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004294
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004295 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4296 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4297 // built in select.
4298 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4299 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4300 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4301 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4302 << CondTy;
4303 return QualType();
4304 }
4305 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4306 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4307 << CondTy;
4308 return QualType();
4309 }
4310 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4311 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4312 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4313 }
4314
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004315 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4316 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004317 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4318 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4319 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004320 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004321
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004322 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4323 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004324 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4325 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004326 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004327 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004328 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004329 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004330 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004331 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004332
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004333 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004334 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004335 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4336 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4337 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4338 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4339 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4340 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4341 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004342 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4343 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004344 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004345 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004346 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4347 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004348 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004349 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004350 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004351 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004352 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004353 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004354 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004355 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004356 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004357 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004358 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004359
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004360 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4361 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4362 QuestionLoc);
4363 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4364 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004365
4366
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004367 // Handle block pointer types.
4368 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4369 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4370 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4371 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004372 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4373 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004374 return destType;
4375 }
4376 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004377 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004378 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004379 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004380 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4381 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4382 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004383 return LHSTy;
4384 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004385 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004386 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4387 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004388
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004389 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4390 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004391 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004392 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004393 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4394 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4395 // to get a consistent AST.
4396 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004397 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4398 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004399 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004400 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004401 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004402 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4403 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004404 return LHSTy;
4405 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004406
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004407 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4408 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4409 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004410 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4411 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004412
4413 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4414 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4415 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004416 QualType destPointee
4417 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004418 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004419 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004420 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004421 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004422 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004423 return destType;
4424 }
4425 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004426 QualType destPointee
4427 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004428 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004429 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004430 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004431 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004432 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004433 return destType;
4434 }
4435
4436 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4437 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4438 return LHSTy;
4439 }
4440 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4441 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4442 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4443 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4444 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4445 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4446 // to get a consistent AST.
4447 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004448 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4449 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004450 return incompatTy;
4451 }
4452 // The pointer types are compatible.
4453 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4454 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4455 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4456 // type.
4457 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4458 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004459 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4460 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004461 return LHSTy;
4462 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004463
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004464 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4465 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4466 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4467 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004468 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004469 return RHSTy;
4470 }
4471 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4472 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4473 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004474 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004475 return LHSTy;
4476 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004477
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004478 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004479 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4480 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004481 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004482}
4483
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004484/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4485/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4486QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4487 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4488 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4489 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004490
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004491 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4492 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4493 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4494 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4495 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004496 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004497 return LHSTy;
4498 }
4499 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4500 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004501 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004502 return RHSTy;
4503 }
4504 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4505 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4506 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004507 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004508 return LHSTy;
4509 }
4510 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4511 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004512 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004513 return RHSTy;
4514 }
4515 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4516 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4517 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004518 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004519 return LHSTy;
4520 }
4521 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4522 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004523 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004524 return RHSTy;
4525 }
4526 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4527 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004528
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004529 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4530 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4531 return LHSTy;
4532 }
4533 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4534 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4535 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004536
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004537 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4538 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4539 // type. This allows
4540 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4541 // where B is a subclass of A.
4542 //
4543 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4544 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4545 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4546 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004547
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004548 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4549 // It could return the composite type.
4550 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4551 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4552 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4553 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4554 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4555 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4556 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4557 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4558 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4559 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4560 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4561 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4562 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4563 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004564 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004565 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4566 ;
4567 else {
4568 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4569 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4570 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4571 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004572 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4573 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004574 return incompatTy;
4575 }
4576 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004577 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4578 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004579 return compositeType;
4580 }
4581 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4582 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4583 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4584 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4585 QualType destPointee
4586 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4587 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4588 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004589 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004590 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004591 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004592 return destType;
4593 }
4594 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4595 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4596 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4597 QualType destPointee
4598 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4599 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4600 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004601 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004602 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004603 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004604 return destType;
4605 }
4606 return QualType();
4607}
4608
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004609/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004610/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004611ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004612 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004613 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4614 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004615 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4616 // was the condition.
4617 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004618 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4619 if (isLHSNull) {
4620 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4621 }
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004622
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004623 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4624 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004625 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004626 return ExprError();
4627
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004628 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004629 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4630 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4631 result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004632}
4633
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004634// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004635// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004636// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4637// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4638// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004639Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004640Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004641 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004642
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004643 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4644 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4645 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4646 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4647 return Compatible;
4648 }
4649
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004650 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004651 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4652 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004653
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004654 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004655 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4656 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004657
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004658 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004659
4660 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4661 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4662 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004663 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004664 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004665 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004666
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004667 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4668 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004669 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004670 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004671 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004672 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004673
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004674 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004675 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4676 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004677 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004678
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004679 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004680 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004681 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004682
4683 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004684 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4685 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004686 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004687 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004688 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004689 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4690 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4691 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4692 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4693 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4694 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004695 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004696 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004697 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004698 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004699
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004700 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004701 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004702 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004703 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004704
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004705 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4706 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4707 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4708 // warning can be disabled.
4709 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4710 return ConvTy;
4711 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4712 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004713
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004714 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4715 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4716 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4717 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4718 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4719 do {
4720 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4721 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004722
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004723 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4724 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4725 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004726
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004727 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004728 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004729 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004730
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004731 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004732 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004733 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004734 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004735}
4736
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004737/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4738/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4739/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4740// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004741Sema::AssignConvertType
4742Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004743 QualType rhsType) {
4744 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004745
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004746 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004747 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4748 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004749
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004750 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4751 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4752 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004753
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004754 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004755
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004756 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004757 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004758 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004759
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004760 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4761 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4762 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4763 }
4764 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004765 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004766 return ConvTy;
4767}
4768
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004769/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4770/// for assignment compatibility.
4771Sema::AssignConvertType
4772Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004773 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4774 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004775 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4776 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004777 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004778 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004779 }
4780 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4781 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004782 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4783 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004784 return IncompatiblePointer;
4785 return Compatible;
4786 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004787 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004788 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004789 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004790 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4791 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4792 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4793 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4794 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4795 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004796
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004797 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4798 return Compatible;
4799 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4800 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004801 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004802}
4803
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004804/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4805/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004806/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4807///
4808/// int a, *pint;
4809/// short *pshort;
4810/// struct foo *pfoo;
4811///
4812/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4813/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4814/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4815/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4816///
4817/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004818/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004819///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004820Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004821Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004822 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4823 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004824 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4825 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004826
4827 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004828 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004829
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004830 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4831 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4832 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4833 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4834 return Compatible;
4835 }
4836
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004837 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4838 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4839 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4840 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4841 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4842 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4843 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004844 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004845 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004846 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004847 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004848 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004849 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4850 // to the same ExtVector type.
4851 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4852 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4853 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004854 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004855 return Compatible;
4856 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004857
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004858 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004859 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4860 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4861 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4862 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4863 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4864 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004865 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004866
4867 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4868 // vector type and vice versa
4869 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4870 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004871 }
4872 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004873 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004874
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004875 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4876 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004877 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004878
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004879 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004880 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004881 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004882
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004883 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004884 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004885
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004886 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004887 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004888 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4889 return Compatible;
4890 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004891 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004892 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4893 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004894 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004895
4896 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004897 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004898 return Compatible;
4899 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004900 return Incompatible;
4901 }
4902
4903 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4904 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004905 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004906
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004907 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004908 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004909 return Compatible;
4910
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004911 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4912 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004913
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004914 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004915 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004916 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004917 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004918 return Incompatible;
4919 }
4920
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004921 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4922 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4923 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004924
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004925 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004926 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004927 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4928 return Compatible;
4929 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004930 }
4931 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004932 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004933 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004934 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004935 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4936 return Compatible;
4937 }
4938 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4939 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4940 return Compatible;
4941 return Incompatible;
4942 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004943 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004944 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004945 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4946 return Compatible;
4947
4948 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004949 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004950
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004951 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004952 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004953
4954 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004955 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004956 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004957 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004958 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004959 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4960 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4961 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4962 return Compatible;
4963
4964 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4965 return PointerToInt;
4966
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004967 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004968 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004969 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4970 return Compatible;
4971 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004972 }
4973 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004974 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004975 return Compatible;
4976 return Incompatible;
4977 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004978
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004979 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004980 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004981 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004982 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004983 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004984}
4985
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004986/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4987/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004988static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004989 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4990 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4991 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004992 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004993 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004994 SourceLocation());
4995 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4996 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4997
4998 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4999 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005000 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005001 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005002 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005003}
5004
5005Sema::AssignConvertType
5006Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5007 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5008
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005009 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005010 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5011 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005012 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005013 return Incompatible;
5014
5015 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5016 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5017 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5018 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005019 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5020 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005021 it != itend; ++it) {
5022 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5023 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5024 // 1) void pointer
5025 // 2) null pointer constant
5026 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005027 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005028 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005029 InitField = *it;
5030 break;
5031 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005032
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005033 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005034 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005035 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005036 InitField = *it;
5037 break;
5038 }
5039 }
5040
5041 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5042 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar60785eb2010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005043 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005044 InitField = *it;
5045 break;
5046 }
5047 }
5048
5049 if (!InitField)
5050 return Incompatible;
5051
5052 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5053 return Compatible;
5054}
5055
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005056Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005057Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005058 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5059 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5060 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5061 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5062 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005063 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005064 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005065 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005066 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005067 }
5068
5069 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5070 // structures.
5071 }
5072
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005073 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5074 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005075 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5076 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005077 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005078 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005079 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005080 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005081 return Compatible;
5082 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005083
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005084 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005085 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005086 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005087 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005088 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005089 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005090 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005091 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005092
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005093 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5094 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005095
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005096 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5097 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005098 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5099 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5100 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5101 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005102 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005103 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005104 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005105 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005106}
5107
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005108QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005109 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005110 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005111 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005112 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005113}
5114
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005115QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005116 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005117 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005118 QualType lhsType =
5119 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5120 QualType rhsType =
5121 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005122
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005123 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005124 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005125 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005126
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005127 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5128 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005129 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005130 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005131 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005132 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005133 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005134 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005135 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005136 return lhsType;
5137 }
5138
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005139 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005140 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005141 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5142 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5143 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5144 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5145 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5146 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005147 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005148 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005149 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005150 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005151
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005152 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5153 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5154 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005155 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005156 return rhsType;
5157 }
5158
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005159 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5160 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5161 bool swapped = false;
5162 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5163 swapped = true;
5164 std::swap(rex, lex);
5165 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5166 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005167
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005168 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005169 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005170 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005171 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005172 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005173 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005174 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5175 return lhsType;
5176 }
5177 }
5178 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5179 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5180 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005181 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005182 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5183 return lhsType;
5184 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005185 }
5186 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005187
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005188 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005189 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005190 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005191 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005192 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005193}
5194
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005195QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5196 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005197 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005198 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005199
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005200 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005201
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005202 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5203 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5204 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005205
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005206 // Check for division by zero.
5207 if (isDiv &&
5208 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005209 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005210 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005211
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005212 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005213}
5214
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005215QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005216 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005217 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005218 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5219 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005220 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5221 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5222 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005223
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005224 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005225
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005226 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5227 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005228
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005229 // Check for remainder by zero.
5230 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005231 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5232 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005233
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005234 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005235}
5236
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005237QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005238 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005239 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5240 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5241 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5242 return compType;
5243 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005244
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005245 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005246
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005247 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005248 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5249 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5250 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005251 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005252 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005253
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005254 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5255 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005256 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005257 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5258
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005259 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005260
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005261 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005262 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005263
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005264 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5265 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005266 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5267 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005268 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005269 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005270 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005271
5272 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5273 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5274 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005275 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005276 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5277 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5278 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5279 return QualType();
5280 }
5281
5282 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5283 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5284 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005285 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005286 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005287 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005288 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005289 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5290 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005291 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5292 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005293 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005294 return QualType();
5295 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005296 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005297 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005298 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5299 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5300 return QualType();
5301 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005302
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005303 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005304 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5305 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5306 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5307 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5308 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005309 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005310 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5311 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005312 return PExp->getType();
5313 }
5314 }
5315
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005316 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005317}
5318
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005319// C99 6.5.6
5320QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005321 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5322 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5323 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5324 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5325 return compType;
5326 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005327
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005328 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005329
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005330 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005331
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005332 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005333 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5334 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005335 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005336 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005337 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005338
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005339 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005340 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005341 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005342
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005343 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005344
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005345 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5346 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5347 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5348 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5349 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5350 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5351 return QualType();
5352 }
5353
5354 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5355 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5356 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5357 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5358 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005359 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005360 return QualType();
5361 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005362
5363 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5364 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5365 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005366 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005367 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005368 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005369 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005370 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005371
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005372 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005373 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005374 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5375 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5376 return QualType();
5377 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005378
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005379 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005380 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5381 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5382 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5383 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5384 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5385 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005386 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005387 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5388
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005389 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005390 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005391 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005392
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005393 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005394 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005395 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005396
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005397 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5398 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5399 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5400 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5401 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5402 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5403 return QualType();
5404 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005405
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005406 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5407 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5408 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5409 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005410 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005411 return QualType();
5412 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005413
5414 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5415 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5416 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5417 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5418 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005419 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5420 << rex->getSourceRange()
5421 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005422 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005423
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005424 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5425 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5426 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5427 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5428 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5429 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5430 return QualType();
5431 }
5432 } else {
5433 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5434 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5435 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5436 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5437 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5438 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5439 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5440 return QualType();
5441 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005442 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005443
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005444 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5445 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5446 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5447 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5448 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005449 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005450 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005451
5452 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005453 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5454 }
5455 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005456
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005457 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005458}
5459
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005460static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5461 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5462 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5463 return false;
5464}
5465
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005466// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005467QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005468 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005469 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005470 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5471 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005472 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005473
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005474 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5475 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5476 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5477 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5478 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5479 }
5480
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005481 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5482 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5483 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5484
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005485 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5486 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005487 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5488 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5489 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5490 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5491 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005492 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005493 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005494 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005495
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005496 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005497
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005498 // Sanity-check shift operands
5499 llvm::APSInt Right;
5500 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005501 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5502 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005503 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005504 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5505 else {
5506 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5507 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5508 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5509 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5510 }
5511 }
5512
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005513 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005514 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005515}
5516
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005517static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5518 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5519 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5520 return true;
5521 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5522 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5523 }
5524 return false;
5525}
5526
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005527// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005528QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005529 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005530 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005531
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005532 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005533 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005534 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005535
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005536 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5537 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005538
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005539 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005540 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5541 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5542 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005543 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5544 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5545 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005546 //
5547 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5548 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5549 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5550 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5551 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5552 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005553 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5554 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005555 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005556 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005557 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005558 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005559 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5560 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005561 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5562 || Opc == BO_LE
5563 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005564 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5565 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5566 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5567 // what is it always going to eval to?
5568 char always_evals_to;
5569 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005570 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005571 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5572 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005573 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005574 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5575 break;
5576 default:
5577 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5578 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5579 break;
5580 }
5581 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5582 << 1 // array
5583 << always_evals_to);
5584 }
5585 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005586 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005587
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005588 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5589 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5590 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5591 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005592
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005593 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5594 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005595 Expr *literalString = 0;
5596 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005597 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005598 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005599 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005600 literalString = lex;
5601 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005602 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5603 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005604 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005605 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005606 literalString = rex;
5607 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5608 }
5609
5610 if (literalString) {
5611 std::string resultComparison;
5612 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005613 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5614 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5615 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5616 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5617 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5618 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005619 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5620 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005621
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005622 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5623 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5624 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005625 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005626 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005627 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005628
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005629 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5630 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5631 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5632 else {
5633 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5634 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5635 }
5636
5637 lType = lex->getType();
5638 rType = rex->getType();
5639
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005640 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005641 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005642
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005643 if (isRelational) {
5644 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005645 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005646 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005647 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005648 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005649 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005650
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005651 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005652 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005653 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005654
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005655 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005656 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005657 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005658 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005659
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005660 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5661 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005662 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005663 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005664 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005665 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005666 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005667
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005668 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005669 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5670 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005671 if (!isRelational &&
5672 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5673 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5674 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005675 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5676 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005677 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5678 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005679 Diag(Loc,
5680 isSFINAEContext()?
5681 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5682 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005683 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005684
5685 if (isSFINAEContext())
5686 return QualType();
5687
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005688 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005689 return ResultTy;
5690 }
5691 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005692 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5693 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5694 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5695 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5696 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5697 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005698 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005699 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005700 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005701 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005702 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005703 if (T.isNull()) {
5704 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5705 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5706 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005707 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005708 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005709 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005710 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005711 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005712 }
5713
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005714 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5715 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005716 return ResultTy;
5717 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005718 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5719 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5720 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5721 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5722 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5723 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5724 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5725 }
5726 } else if (!isRelational &&
5727 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5728 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5729 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5730 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5731 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5732 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5733 }
5734 } else {
5735 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005736 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005737 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005738 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005739 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005740 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005741 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005742 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005743
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005744 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005745 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005746 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005747 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005748 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5749 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005750 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5751 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005752 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5753 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005754 return ResultTy;
5755 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005756 if (LHSIsNull &&
5757 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5758 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005759 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5760 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005761 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5762 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005763 return ResultTy;
5764 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005765
5766 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005767 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005768 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5769 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005770 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5771 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5772 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5773 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5774 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5775 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5776 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5777 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005778 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005779 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005780 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005781 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005782 if (T.isNull()) {
5783 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005784 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005785 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005786 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005787 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005788 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005789 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005790 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005791 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005792
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005793 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5794 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005795 return ResultTy;
5796 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005797
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005798 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005799 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5800 return ResultTy;
5801 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005802
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005803 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005804 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005805 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5806 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005807
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005808 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005809 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005810 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005811 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005812 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005813 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005814 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005815 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005816 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005817 if (!isRelational
5818 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5819 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005820 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005821 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005822 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005823 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005824 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5825 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5826 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005827 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005828 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005829 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005830 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005831
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005832 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005833 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005834 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5835 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005836 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005837 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005838 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005839 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005840
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005841 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5842 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005843 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005844 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005845 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005846 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005847 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005848 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005849 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005850 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005851 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5852 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005853 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005854 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005855 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005856 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005857 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5858 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005859 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005860 bool isError = false;
5861 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5862 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5863 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005864 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005865 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005866 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005867 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5868 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5869 isError = true;
5870 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005871 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005872
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005873 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005874 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005875 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005876 if (isError)
5877 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005878 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005879
5880 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005881 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005882 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005883 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005884 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005885 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005886
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005887 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005888 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5889 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005890 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005891 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005892 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005893 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5894 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005895 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005896 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005897 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005898 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005899}
5900
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005901/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005902/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005903/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5904/// types.
5905QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005906 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005907 bool isRelational) {
5908 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5909 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005910 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005911 if (vType.isNull())
5912 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005913
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005914 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5915 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005916
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005917 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5918 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5919 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005920 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005921 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5922 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5923 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005924 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5925 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5926 << 0 // self-
5927 << 2 // "a constant"
5928 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005929 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005930
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005931 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005932 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5933 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005934 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005935 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005936
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005937 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5938 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5939 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005940 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005941 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005942
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005943 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005944 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005945 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005946 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005947 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005948 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5949
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005950 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005951 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005952 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5953}
5954
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005955inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005956 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005957 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5958 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5959 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5960 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5961
5962 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5963 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005964
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005965 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005966
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005967 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5968 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005969 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005970 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005971}
5972
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005973inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005974 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5975
5976 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5977 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5978 // is a constant.
5979 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005980 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005981 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005982 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5983 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5984 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5985 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5986 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5987 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5988 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5989 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5990 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005991 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5992 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005993 }
5994 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005995
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005996 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5997 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5998 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005999
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006000 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6001 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006002
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006003 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006004 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006005
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006006 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6007 // non-overloadable operands.
6008
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006009 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6010 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006011 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6012 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6013 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006014 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006015
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006016 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6017 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6018 // The result is a bool.
6019 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006020}
6021
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006022/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6023/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6024/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6025///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006026static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006027 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6028 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6029 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006030 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6031 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6032 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6033
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006034 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006035 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6036 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6037 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6038 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006039 }
6040 }
6041 return false;
6042}
6043
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006044/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6045/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6046static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006047 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006048 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006049 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006050 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6051 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006052 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6053 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006054
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006055 unsigned Diag = 0;
6056 bool NeedType = false;
6057 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006058 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006059 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006060 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6061 NeedType = true;
6062 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006063 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006064 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6065 NeedType = true;
6066 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006067 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006068 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6069 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006070 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6071 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006072 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006073 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6074 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006075 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6076 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006077 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6078 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006079 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006080 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006081 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006082 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006083 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6084 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006085 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006086 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6087 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006088 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6089 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6090 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006091 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6092 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6093 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006094 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6095 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6096 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006097 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006098
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006099 SourceRange Assign;
6100 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6101 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006102 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006103 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006104 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006105 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006106 return true;
6107}
6108
6109
6110
6111// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006112QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6113 SourceLocation Loc,
6114 QualType CompoundType) {
6115 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6116 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006117 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006118
6119 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6120 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006121 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006122 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006123 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006124 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006125 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006126 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006127 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6128 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6129 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006130 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006131 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006132 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006133 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006134
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006135 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6136 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6137 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006138 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006139 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6140 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6141 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006142 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6143 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006144 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006145 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006146 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6147 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6148 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006149 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6150 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006151 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006152 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006153 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006154 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006155 }
6156 } else {
6157 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006158 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006159 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006160
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006161 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006162 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006163 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006164
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006165
6166 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6167 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6168 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6169 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6170 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6171 // check.
6172 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006173 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006174 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6175 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6176 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6177 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6178 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6179 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6180 }
6181
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006182 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6183 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006184 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006185 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6186 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006187 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006188 // operand.
John McCall01cbf2d2010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006189 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6190 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006191}
6192
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006193// C99 6.5.17
6194QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006195 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6196
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006197 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6198 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6199 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6200 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6201 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6202 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6203 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006204
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006205 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6206 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6207 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6208 }
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006209
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006210 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006211}
6212
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006213/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6214/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006215QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006216 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006217 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6218 return Context.DependentTy;
6219
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006220 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6221 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006222
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006223 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6224 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6225 if (!isInc) {
6226 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6227 return QualType();
6228 }
6229 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6230 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6231 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006232 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006233 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6234 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006235
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006236 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006237 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006238 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6239 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6240 << Op->getSourceRange();
6241 return QualType();
6242 }
6243
6244 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006245 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006246 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006247 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6248 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6249 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6250 return QualType();
6251 }
6252
6253 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006254 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006255 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006256 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006257 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006258 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006259 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006260 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006261 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006262 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6263 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6264 return QualType();
6265 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006266 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006267 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6268 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006269 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006270 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6271 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6272 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6273 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006274 } else {
6275 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006276 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006277 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006278 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006279 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006280 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006281 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006282 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006283 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6284 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6285 // operand.
6286 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6287 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006288}
6289
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006290void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6291 bool copyInit = false;
6292 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6293 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6294 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6295 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6296 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6297 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6298 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6299 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6300 }
6301 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6302 }
6303 else
6304 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6305 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6306 if (copyInit) {
6307 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006308 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006309 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6310 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6311 Owned(Arg));
6312 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006313 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006314 }
6315}
6316
6317
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006318/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006319/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006320/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6321/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6322/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6323/// - &(x) => x
6324/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6325/// - &s.xx => s
6326/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6327/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6328/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6329/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006330static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006331 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006332 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006333 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006334 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006335 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6336 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6337 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006338 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006339 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006340 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006341 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006342 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006343 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6344 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006345 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6346 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6347 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6348 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6349 }
6350 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006351 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006352 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6353 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006354
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006355 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006356 case UO_Real:
6357 case UO_Imag:
6358 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006359 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6360 default:
6361 return 0;
6362 }
6363 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006364 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006365 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006366 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006367 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6368 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006369 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006370 default:
6371 return 0;
6372 }
6373}
6374
6375/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006376/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006377/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006378/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006379/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006380/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006381/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006382QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6383 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006384 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006385 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6386 return Context.OverloadTy;
6387
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006388 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6389 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6390 OrigOp = PR.take();
6391
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006392 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6393 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006394
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006395 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6396 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6397 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006398 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006399 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6400 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6401 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6402 }
6403 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6404 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6405 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006406 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006407 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006408
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006409 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006410 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6411 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6412 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6413 if (isSFINAEContext())
6414 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006415 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006416 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006417 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6418 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6419 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6420
6421 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6422 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6423 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6424 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6425 return QualType();
6426 }
6427 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6428 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6429
6430 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6431 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6432 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6433 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6434
6435 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6436 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6437 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6438 << op->getSourceRange();
6439 }
6440
6441 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6442 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6443 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006444 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006445 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006446 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006447 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006448 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6449 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006450 return QualType();
6451 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006452 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006453 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6454 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6455 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006456 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006457 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006458 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006459 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006460 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006461 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006462 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6463 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6464 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6465 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6466 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006467 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6468 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006469 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6470 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006471 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006472 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006473 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6474 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006475 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6476 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006477 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006478 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006479 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6480 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006481 return QualType();
6482 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006483 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006484 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006485 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006486 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006487 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6488 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006489 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006490 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006491 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6492 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006493 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006494 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6495 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6496 return QualType();
6497 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006498
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006499 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6500 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006501 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006502 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006503 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006504 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006505 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006506
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006507 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6508 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6509 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6510 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6511 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6512 }
6513
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006514 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006515 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6516 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006517 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006518}
6519
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006520/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006521QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006522 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6523 return Context.DependentTy;
6524
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006525 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006526 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6527 QualType Result;
6528
6529 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6530 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6531 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6532 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6533 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6534 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6535 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6536 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6537 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006538 else {
6539 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6540 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6541 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6542 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006543
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006544 if (Result.isNull()) {
6545 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6546 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6547 return QualType();
6548 }
6549
6550 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006551}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006552
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006553static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006554 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006555 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006556 switch (Kind) {
6557 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006558 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6559 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6560 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6561 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6562 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6563 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6564 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6565 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6566 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6567 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6568 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6569 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6570 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6571 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6572 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6573 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6574 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6575 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6576 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6577 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6578 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6579 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6580 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6581 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6582 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6583 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6584 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6585 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6586 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6587 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6588 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6589 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006590 }
6591 return Opc;
6592}
6593
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006594static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006595 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006596 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006597 switch (Kind) {
6598 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006599 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6600 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6601 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6602 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6603 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6604 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6605 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6606 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6607 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6608 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6609 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006610 }
6611 return Opc;
6612}
6613
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006614/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6615/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6616/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006617ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006618 unsigned Op,
6619 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006620 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006621 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006622 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6623 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6624 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006625
6626 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006627 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006628 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6629 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006630 case BO_PtrMemD:
6631 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006632 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006633 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006634 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006635 case BO_Mul:
6636 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006637 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006638 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006639 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006640 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006641 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6642 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006643 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006644 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6645 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006646 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006647 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6648 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006649 case BO_Shl:
6650 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006651 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6652 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006653 case BO_LE:
6654 case BO_LT:
6655 case BO_GE:
6656 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006657 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006658 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006659 case BO_EQ:
6660 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006661 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006662 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006663 case BO_And:
6664 case BO_Xor:
6665 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006666 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6667 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006668 case BO_LAnd:
6669 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006670 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006671 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006672 case BO_MulAssign:
6673 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006674 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006675 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006676 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6677 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6678 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006679 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006680 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006681 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6682 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6683 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6684 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006685 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006686 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006687 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6688 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6689 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006690 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006691 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006692 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6693 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6694 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006695 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006696 case BO_ShlAssign:
6697 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006698 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6699 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6700 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6701 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006702 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006703 case BO_AndAssign:
6704 case BO_XorAssign:
6705 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006706 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6707 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6708 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6709 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006710 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006711 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006712 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6713 break;
6714 }
6715 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006716 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006717 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006718 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006719 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6720 << ResultTy;
6721 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006722 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006723 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6724 else
6725 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006726 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6727 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006728}
6729
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006730/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6731/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006732static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6733 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006734 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6735 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6736 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006737 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006738 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6739
6740 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6741 return;
6742
6743 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6744 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6745 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006746 return;
6747 }
6748
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006749 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6750 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006751 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006752
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006753 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006754 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006755
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006756 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6757 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6758 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6759 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006760 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006761 return;
6762 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006763
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006764 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006765 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6766 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006767}
6768
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006769/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6770/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6771/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6772/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006773static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006774 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006775 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6776 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6777 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6778 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006779 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006780 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006781 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6782
6783 // Subs are not binary operators.
6784 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6785 return;
6786
6787 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6788 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006789 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6790 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006791 return;
6792
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006793 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006794 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006795 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006796 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6797 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006798 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006799 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006800 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6801 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6802 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6803 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006804 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006805 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006806 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006807 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6808 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006809 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006810 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006811 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6812 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6813 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6814 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006815}
6816
6817/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6818/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6819/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006820static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006821 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006822 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006823 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6824}
6825
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006826// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006827ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006828 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6829 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6830 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006831 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6832 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006833
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006834 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6835 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6836
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006837 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6838}
6839
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006840ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006841 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6842 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006843 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006844 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6845 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianaaf44b22010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006846 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006847 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006848 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6849 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6850 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6851 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6852 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006853 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006854 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006855 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6856 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6857 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006858
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006859 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6860 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006861 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006862 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006863
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006864 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006865 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006866}
6867
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006868ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006869 unsigned OpcIn,
6870 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006871 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006872
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006873 QualType resultType;
6874 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006875 case UO_PreInc:
6876 case UO_PreDec:
6877 case UO_PostInc:
6878 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006879 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006880 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6881 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6882 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6883 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006884 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006885 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006886 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006887 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006888 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006889 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006890 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006891 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006892 case UO_Plus:
6893 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006894 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6895 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006896 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6897 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006898 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6899 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006900 break;
6901 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6902 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6903 break;
6904 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006905 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006906 resultType->isPointerType())
6907 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006908 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6909 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6910 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6911 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6912 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006913
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006914 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6915 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006916 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006917 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6918 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006919 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6920 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006921 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6922 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6923 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006924 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006925 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006926 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6927 break;
6928 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6929 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6930 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6931 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6932 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006933 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6934 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006935 }
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006936 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006937 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006938 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006939 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006940 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006941 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6942 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006943 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6944 // ok, fallthrough
6945 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6946 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6947 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6948 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6949 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006950 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6951 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006952 }
Douglas Gregordb8c6fd2010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006953
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006954 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006955 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6956 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006957 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006958 case UO_Real:
6959 case UO_Imag:
6960 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006961 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006962 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006963 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006964 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006965 }
6966 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006967 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006968
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006969 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006970}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006971
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006972ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006973 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6974 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006975 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman8ed2bac2010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006976 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006977 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6978 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6979 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6980 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006981 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006982 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006983 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6984 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6985 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006986
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006987 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006988 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006989
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006990 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006991}
6992
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006993// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006994ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006995 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6996 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006997}
6998
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006999/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007000ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007001 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7002 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007003 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007004 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007005
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007006 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7007 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007008 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007009 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007010
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007011 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007012 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007013 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7014 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007015}
7016
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007017ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007018Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007019 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007020 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7021 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7022
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007023 bool isFileScope
7024 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007025 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007026 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007027
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007028 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7029 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7030 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007031
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007032 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7033 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7034 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007035
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007036 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7037 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
7038 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
7039 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
7040 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007041
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007042 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007043 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007044 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007045
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007046 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7047 // expressions are not lvalues.
7048
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007049 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007050}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007051
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007052ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007053 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7054 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7055 unsigned NumComponents,
7056 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007057 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007058 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007059 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007060
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007061 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7062 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7063 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007064 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007065 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7066 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7067
7068 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7069 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7070 if (!Dependent
7071 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7072 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7073 << TypeRange))
7074 return ExprError();
7075
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007076 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7077 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007078 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7079 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007080 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007081 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7082 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007083
7084 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7085 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7086 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7087 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7088 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7089 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7090 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7091 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7092 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7093 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7094 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7095 if(!AT)
7096 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7097 << CurrentType);
7098 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7099 } else
7100 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7101
7102 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7103 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7104 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7105 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7106 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7107 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7108 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7109 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7110
7111 // Record this array index.
7112 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7113 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7114 continue;
7115 }
7116
7117 // Offset of a field.
7118 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7119 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7120 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7121 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7122 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7123 continue;
7124 }
7125
7126 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7127 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7128 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7129 return ExprError();
7130
7131 // Look for the designated field.
7132 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7133 if (!RC)
7134 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7135 << CurrentType);
7136 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7137
7138 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7139 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7140 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7141 // (clause 9).
7142 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7143 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7144 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7145 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7146 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7147 << CurrentType))
7148 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7149 }
7150
7151 // Look for the field.
7152 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7153 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7154 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7155 if (!MemberDecl)
7156 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7157 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7158 OC.LocEnd));
7159
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007160 // C99 7.17p3:
7161 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7162 //
7163 // We diagnose this as an error.
7164 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7165 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7166 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7167 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7168 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7169 return ExprError();
7170 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007171
7172 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7173 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7174 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7175 do {
7176 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7177 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7178 }
7179
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007180 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7181 // the base class indirections.
7182 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7183 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007184 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007185 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7186 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7187 B != BEnd; ++B)
7188 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7189 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007190
7191 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007192 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7193 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7194 unsigned n = Path.size();
7195 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7196 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7197 } else {
7198 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7199 }
7200 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7201 }
7202
7203 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7204 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7205 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7206}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007207
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007208ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007209 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7210 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7211 ParsedType argty,
7212 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7213 unsigned NumComponents,
7214 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7215
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007216 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7217 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7218 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7219 return ExprError();
7220
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007221 if (!ArgTInfo)
7222 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7223
7224 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7225 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007226}
7227
7228
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007229ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007230 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7231 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007232 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7233 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7234 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7235 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007236
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007237 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007238
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007239 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7240}
7241
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007242ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007243Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7244 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7245 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7246 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007247 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7248 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7249 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7250 return ExprError();
7251 }
7252
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007253 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007254 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007255}
7256
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007257
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007258ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007259 Expr *CondExpr,
7260 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7261 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007262 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7263
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007264 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007265 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007266 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007267 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007268 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007269 } else {
7270 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7271 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7272 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7273 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007274 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7275 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7276 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007277
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007278 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7279 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007280 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7281 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007282 }
7283
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007284 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007285 resType, RPLoc,
7286 resType->isDependentType(),
7287 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007288}
7289
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007290//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7291// Clang Extensions.
7292//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7293
7294/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007295void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007296 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7297 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7298 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007299 if (BlockScope)
7300 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7301 else
7302 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007303}
7304
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007305void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007306 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007307 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007308
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007309 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007310 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007311 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007312
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007313 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007314 QualType RetTy;
7315 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007316 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007317 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007318 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007319 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7320 } else {
7321 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007322 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007323 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007324
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007325 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007326
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007327 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7328 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7329 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007330 return;
7331 }
7332
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007333 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7334 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7335 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7336 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7337 return;
7338 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007339
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007340 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007341 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7342 // ^ * { ... }
7343 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007344 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7345 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007346
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007347 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007348 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007349 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7350 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7351 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7352 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007353 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7354 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7355 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7356 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7357 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007358 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007359 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007360
7361 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7362 // ^ fntype { ... }
7363 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7364 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7365 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7366 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7367 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7368 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7369 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007370 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007371 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007372 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007373
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007374 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7375 if (!Params.empty())
7376 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007377
7378 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007379 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007380
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007381 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007382 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7383 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7384 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7385 }
7386
7387 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7388 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007389 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007390 return;
7391
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007392 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7393 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7394
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007395 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007396 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7397 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7398
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007399 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007400 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7401 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7402 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7403
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007404 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007405 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007406 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007407}
7408
7409/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7410/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7411void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007412 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007413 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007414 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007415 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007416}
7417
7418/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7419/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007420ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007421 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007422 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7423 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7424 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007425
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007426 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007427
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007428 PopDeclContext();
7429
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007430 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007431 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7432 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007433
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007434 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007435 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007436
7437 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7438 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7439 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7440
7441 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7442 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7443
7444 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7445 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7446 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7447 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7448
7449 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7450 // preserve its sugar structure.
7451 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7452 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7453 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7454
7455 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7456 } else {
7457 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7458 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7459 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7460 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7461 FPT->isVariadic(),
7462 /*quals*/ 0,
7463 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7464 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7465 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7466 FPT->exception_begin(),
7467 Ext);
7468 }
7469
7470 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7471 } else {
7472 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7473 false, false, 0, 0,
7474 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7475 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007476
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007477 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007478 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7479 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007480 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007481
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007482 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007483 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007484 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007485
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007486 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007487
7488 bool Good = true;
7489 // Check goto/label use.
7490 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7491 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7492 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7493
7494 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7495 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007496 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7497 if (!L->isUsed())
7498 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007499 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007500 }
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007501
7502 // Emit error.
7503 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7504 Good = false;
7505 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007506 if (!Good) {
7507 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007508 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007509 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007510
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007511 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7512 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7513
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007514 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007515 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7516 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007517 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007518
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007519 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007520 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007521}
7522
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007523ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007524 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007525 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007526 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7527 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007528 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007529}
7530
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007531ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007532 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007533 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007534 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007535
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007536 // Get the va_list type
7537 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007538 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7539 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7540 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7541 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007542 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007543 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7544 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7545 } else {
7546 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7547 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007548 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007549 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007550 return ExprError();
7551 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007552
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007553 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7554 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007555 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7556 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007557 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007558 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007559
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007560 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007561 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007562
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007563 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7564 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007565}
7566
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007567ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007568 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7569 // pointers on the target.
7570 QualType Ty;
7571 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7572 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7573 else
7574 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7575
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007576 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007577}
7578
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007579static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007580 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007581 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7582 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007583
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007584 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7585 if (!PT)
7586 return;
7587
7588 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7589 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7590 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7591 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7592 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7593 return;
7594 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007595
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007596 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7597 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7598 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7599 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007600
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007601 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007602}
7603
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007604bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7605 SourceLocation Loc,
7606 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007607 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7608 bool *Complained) {
7609 if (Complained)
7610 *Complained = false;
7611
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007612 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7613 bool isInvalid = false;
7614 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007615 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007616
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007617 switch (ConvTy) {
7618 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7619 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007620 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007621 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7622 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007623 case IntToPointer:
7624 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7625 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007626 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007627 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007628 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7629 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007630 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7631 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7632 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007633 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7634 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7635 break;
7636 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007637 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7638 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7639 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7640 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7641 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7642 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7643 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7644 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7645 // C++ semantics.
7646 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7647 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7648 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007649 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7650 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007651 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007652 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007653 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007654 case IntToBlockPointer:
7655 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7656 break;
7657 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007658 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007659 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007660 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007661 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007662 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7663 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7664 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007665 case IncompatibleVectors:
7666 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7667 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007668 case Incompatible:
7669 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7670 isInvalid = true;
7671 break;
7672 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007673
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007674 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7675 switch (Action) {
7676 case AA_Assigning:
7677 case AA_Initializing:
7678 // The destination type comes first.
7679 FirstType = DstType;
7680 SecondType = SrcType;
7681 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007682
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007683 case AA_Returning:
7684 case AA_Passing:
7685 case AA_Converting:
7686 case AA_Sending:
7687 case AA_Casting:
7688 // The source type comes first.
7689 FirstType = SrcType;
7690 SecondType = DstType;
7691 break;
7692 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007693
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007694 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007695 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007696 if (Complained)
7697 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007698 return isInvalid;
7699}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007700
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007701bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007702 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7703 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7704 if (Result)
7705 *Result = ICEResult;
7706 return false;
7707 }
7708
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007709 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7710
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007711 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007712 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7713 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7714
7715 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7716 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7717 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7718 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7719 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7720 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7721 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007722
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007723 return true;
7724 }
7725
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007726 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7727 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007728
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007729 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7730 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7731 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007732
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007733 if (Result)
7734 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7735 return false;
7736}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007737
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007738void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007739Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007740 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7741 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007742}
7743
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007744void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007745Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7746 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7747 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7748 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007749
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007750 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7751 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7752 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7753 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7754 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007755 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007756 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7757 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7758 I != IEnd; ++I)
7759 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7760 }
7761
7762 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7763 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7764 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7765 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7766 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7767 I != IEnd; ++I)
7768 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7769 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007770 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007771
7772 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7773 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7774 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7775 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007776 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007777 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7778 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7779 ExprTemporaries.end());
7780
7781 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7782 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007783}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007784
7785/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7786///
7787/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7788/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7789/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7790/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7791///
7792/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7793///
7794/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7795void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7796 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007797
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007798 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007799 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007800
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007801 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7802 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7803 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7804 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007805 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007806 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007807 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007808 return;
7809 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007810
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007811 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7812 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007813
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007814 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7815 // an instantiation.
7816 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7817 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007818
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007819 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007820 case Unevaluated:
7821 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7822 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007823
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007824 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7825 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7826 // "used"; handle this below.
7827 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007828
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007829 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7830 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7831 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7832 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007833 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007834 return;
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007835
7836 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7837 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7838 // containing expression is used.
7839 return;
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007840 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007841
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007842 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007843 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007844 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007845 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007846 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7847 return;
7848 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7849 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007850 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007851 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007852 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007853 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7854 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007855
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007856 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007857 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007858 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007859 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007860 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7861 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007862 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7863 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7864 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007865 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007866 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007867 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7868 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007869 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007870 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007871 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007872 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007873 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007874 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7875 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7876 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7877 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7878 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007879 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007880 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007881 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007882 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007883 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7884 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7885 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007886 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007887 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007888 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7889 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007890
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007891 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7892 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7893 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7894 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7895 Loc));
7896 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007897 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007898 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007899 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7900 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7901 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007902 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007903 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7904 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007905
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007906 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007907
7908 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7909 if (CurContext != Function)
7910 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007911
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007912 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007913 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007914
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007915 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007916 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007917 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007918 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7919 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7920 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7921 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7922 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7923 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007924 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007925 }
7926 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007927
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007928 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007929
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007930 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007931 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007932 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007933}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007934
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007935namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007936 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007937 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007938 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007939 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7940 Sema &S;
7941 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007942
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007943 public:
7944 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007945
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007946 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007947
7948 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7949 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007950 };
7951}
7952
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007953bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7954 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007955 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7956 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7957 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007958
7959 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007960}
7961
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007962bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007963 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7964 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7965 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007966 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7967 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007968 }
7969
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007970 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007971}
7972
7973void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7974 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007975 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007976}
7977
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007978namespace {
7979 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
7980 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7981 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
7982 Sema &S;
7983
7984 public:
7985 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
7986
7987 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
7988
7989 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
7990 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7991 }
7992
7993 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
7994 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007995 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007996 }
7997
7998 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
7999 if (E->getConstructor())
8000 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8001 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8002 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8003 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8004 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008005 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008006 }
8007
8008 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8009 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8010 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008011 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8012 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8013 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8014 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8015 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8016 }
8017
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008018 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008019 }
8020
8021 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8022 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008023 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008024 }
8025
8026 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8027 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8028 }
Douglas Gregorf0873f42010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008029
8030 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8031 Visit(E->getExpr());
8032 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008033 };
8034}
8035
8036/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8037/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8038void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8039 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8040}
8041
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008042/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8043/// of the program being compiled.
8044///
8045/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008046/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008047/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8048/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8049/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8050/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008051/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008052/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008053///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008054/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8055/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8056/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8057/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008058bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008059 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8060 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8061 case Unevaluated:
8062 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8063 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008064
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008065 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008066 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008067 Diag(Loc, PD);
8068 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008069
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008070 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8071 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8072 break;
8073 }
8074
8075 return false;
8076}
8077
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008078bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8079 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8080 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8081 return false;
8082
8083 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8084 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8085 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8086 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008087
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008088 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008089 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008090 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8091 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008092 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008093 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8094 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8095 return true;
8096
8097 return false;
8098}
8099
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008100// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8101// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8102void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8103 SourceLocation Loc;
8104
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008105 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8106
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008107 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8108 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008109 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008110 return;
8111
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008112 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8113 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8114 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8115 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8116
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008117 // self = [<foo> init...]
8118 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8119 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8120 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8121
8122 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8123 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8124 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8125 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8126 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008127
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008128 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8129 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8130 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8131 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8132 return;
8133
8134 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8135 } else {
8136 // Not an assignment.
8137 return;
8138 }
8139
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008140 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008141 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008142
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008143 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008144 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008145 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008146 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8147 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8148 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008149}
8150
8151bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8152 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8153
8154 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008155 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008156
8157 QualType T = E->getType();
8158
8159 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8160 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8161 return true;
8162 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8163 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8164 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8165 return true;
8166 }
8167 }
8168
8169 return false;
8170}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008171
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008172ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8173 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008174 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008175 return ExprError();
8176
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008177 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008178 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008179
8180 return Owned(Sub);
8181}
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008182
8183/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8184/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8185ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8186 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8187 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8188
8189 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8190 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8191 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8192 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8193 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8194 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8195 Specialization->getAccess());
8196 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8197 if (!E) return ExprError();
8198 return Owned(E);
8199 }
8200
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008201 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008202 return ExprError();
8203 }
8204
8205 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8206 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8207
8208 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8209 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8210 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8211 return ExprError();
8212}